1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-psinfo.h"
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
56 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
70 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
102 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
124 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
152 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
180 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
199 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
204 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
207 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
215 return h & 0xffffffff;
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
224 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 unsigned long h = 5381;
228 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 return h & 0xffffffff;
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id)
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
245 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
251 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
272 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
284 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
286 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
290 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 if (shstrtab == NULL)
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
301 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
303 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
305 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
306 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
307 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
309 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
310 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
311 the string table over and over. */
312 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
315 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
316 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
318 return (char *) shstrtab;
322 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
323 unsigned int shindex,
324 unsigned int strindex)
326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
331 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
334 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
336 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
338 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
340 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
341 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: attempt to load strings from a non-string section (number %d)"),
346 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
350 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
352 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
353 (*_bfd_error_handler)
354 (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
355 abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
356 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
358 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
362 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
365 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
366 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
367 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
368 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
369 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
370 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
371 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
374 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
375 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
378 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
380 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
382 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
384 const bfd_byte *esym;
385 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
386 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
387 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
388 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
389 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
390 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
395 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
401 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
403 if (symtab_hdr == &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_hdr)
404 shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
406 /* Read the symbols. */
408 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
410 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
411 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
412 amt = symcount * extsym_size;
413 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
414 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
416 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
417 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
419 if (extsym_buf == NULL
420 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
421 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
427 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
431 amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
432 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
433 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
435 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
436 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
437 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
439 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
440 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
441 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
448 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
450 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
451 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
452 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
453 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
457 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
458 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
459 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
460 shndx = extshndx_buf;
462 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
463 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
465 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
466 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
467 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
468 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
469 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
476 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
478 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
479 free (alloc_extshndx);
484 /* Look up a symbol name. */
486 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
487 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
488 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
492 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
493 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
495 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
496 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
497 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
499 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
500 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
503 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
506 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
507 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
512 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
513 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
516 typedef union elf_internal_group {
517 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
519 } Elf_Internal_Group;
521 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
522 signature just a string? */
525 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
527 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
528 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
529 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
530 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
532 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
533 that it is a symbol table section. */
534 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
536 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
537 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
538 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
541 /* Go read the symbol. */
542 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
543 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
544 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
547 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
550 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
553 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
555 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
557 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
558 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
561 unsigned int i, shnum;
563 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
564 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
565 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
568 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
569 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
570 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
571 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
572 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
574 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
576 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
578 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
584 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
585 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
589 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
590 so we can find them quickly. */
593 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
594 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
595 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
596 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
600 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
602 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
604 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
607 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
609 /* Add to list of sections. */
610 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
613 /* Read the raw contents. */
614 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
615 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
616 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
617 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
618 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
619 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
622 (_("%B: corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
623 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
628 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
630 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
631 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
635 (_("%B: invalid size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
636 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
638 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even partially
639 corrupt, do not allow any of the contents to be used. */
640 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
644 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
645 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
646 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
648 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
649 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
657 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
658 if (src == shdr->contents)
661 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
662 shdr->bfd_section->flags
663 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
668 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
669 (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
672 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
677 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
678 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
680 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
682 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
685 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
686 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
687 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
688 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
694 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
698 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
700 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
701 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
702 unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
704 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
705 section is a member. */
707 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
711 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
712 other members to see if any others are linked via
714 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
715 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
717 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
718 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
722 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
723 insert current section in circular list. */
724 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
725 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
726 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
732 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
735 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
737 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
738 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
741 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
743 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
744 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
752 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
754 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
762 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
765 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
766 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
769 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
770 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
772 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
773 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
775 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
776 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
777 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
778 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
781 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
782 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
783 bed->link_order_error_handler
784 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
789 asection *linksec = NULL;
791 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
793 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
794 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
798 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
799 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
802 (*_bfd_error_handler)
803 (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
804 s->owner, s, elfsec);
808 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
813 /* Process section groups. */
814 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
817 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
819 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
820 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
823 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
824 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
826 (*_bfd_error_handler)
827 (_("%B: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
833 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
834 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
837 if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
838 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
839 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
840 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
841 /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
842 output object files. We adjust the group section size here
843 so that relocatable link will work correctly when
844 relocation sections are in section group in input object
846 shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
849 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
850 (*_bfd_error_handler)
851 (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
853 (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
854 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
855 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
858 shdr->bfd_section->name);
866 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
868 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
872 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
874 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
875 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
876 if (new_name == NULL)
880 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
885 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
887 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
888 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
889 if (new_name == NULL)
892 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
896 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
897 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
900 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
901 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
907 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
909 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
912 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
916 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
917 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
918 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
920 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
921 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
922 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
924 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
926 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
927 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
928 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
929 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
932 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
933 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
934 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
935 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
936 flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
937 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
940 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
943 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
944 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
945 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
947 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
949 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
952 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
953 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
954 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
956 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
957 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
959 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
960 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
961 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
962 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
964 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
966 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
967 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
974 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
975 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
976 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
977 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
978 else if (name[1] == 'l')
980 else if (name[1] == 's')
982 else if (name[1] == 'z')
983 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
986 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
987 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
991 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
992 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
993 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
994 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
995 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
996 all but one of the sections. */
997 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
998 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
999 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1001 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1002 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1003 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1006 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1009 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1010 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1011 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1012 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1016 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1019 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
1023 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1025 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1026 unsigned int i, nload;
1028 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1029 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1030 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1031 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1032 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1033 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1034 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1036 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1038 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1041 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1042 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1044 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1045 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1046 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1047 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1049 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1050 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1051 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1053 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1054 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1055 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1056 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1057 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1058 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1059 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1060 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1061 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1063 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1064 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1065 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1066 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1067 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1068 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1069 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1075 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1076 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1077 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1078 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1079 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1081 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1082 int compression_header_size;
1083 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1084 bfd_boolean compressed
1085 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1086 &compression_header_size,
1087 &uncompressed_size);
1091 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1092 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1093 action = decompress;
1096 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1097 section. Check if we should compress. */
1098 if (action == nothing)
1100 if (newsect->size != 0
1101 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1102 && compression_header_size >= 0
1103 && uncompressed_size > 0
1105 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1106 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1112 if (action == compress)
1114 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1116 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1117 (_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1124 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1126 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1127 (_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1133 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1136 && (action == decompress
1137 || (action == compress
1138 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1140 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1141 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1143 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1144 if (new_name == NULL)
1146 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1150 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1151 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1152 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1158 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
1159 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1160 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1161 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1164 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1165 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1166 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1167 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1168 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1169 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1170 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1171 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1172 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1174 bfd_reloc_status_type
1175 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1176 arelent *reloc_entry,
1178 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1179 asection *input_section,
1181 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1183 if (output_bfd != NULL
1184 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1185 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1186 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1188 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1189 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1192 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1195 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1199 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1201 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1202 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1205 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1207 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1208 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1211 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1213 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1214 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1215 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1217 /* Copy object attributes. */
1218 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1220 /* This is an feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug: When a section's type
1221 is changed to NOBITS, we preserve the sh_link and sh_info fields so that
1222 they can be matched up with the original. */
1223 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** iheaders = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1224 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1226 if (iheaders != NULL && oheaders != NULL)
1230 for (i = 0; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1233 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1236 || oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1237 || oheader->sh_size == 0
1238 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1241 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1242 FIXME: We could use something better than a linear scan here.
1243 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1244 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1245 for (j = 0; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1247 Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1249 /* Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections
1250 into SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type
1251 matches any input type. */
1252 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1253 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1254 && iheader->sh_flags == oheader->sh_flags
1255 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1256 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1257 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1258 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1259 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1260 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1262 /* Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1263 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1264 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1265 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But the
1266 whole point of this action is to preserve the original
1267 values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so that they
1268 can be matched up with the section headers in the
1269 original file. So strictly speaking we may be creating
1270 an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file that just
1271 contains debug info and only for sections without any
1273 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1274 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1275 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1276 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1287 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1292 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1293 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1294 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1295 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1296 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1297 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1298 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1299 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1300 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1301 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1302 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1303 default: pt = NULL; break;
1308 /* Print out the program headers. */
1311 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1313 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1314 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1316 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1318 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1323 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1324 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1325 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1327 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1332 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1335 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1336 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1337 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1338 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1339 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1340 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1341 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1342 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1343 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1344 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1345 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1346 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1347 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1348 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1349 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1350 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1351 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1356 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1359 unsigned int elfsec;
1360 unsigned long shlink;
1361 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1363 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1365 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1367 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1370 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1371 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1373 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1375 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1376 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1379 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1380 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1382 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1383 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1385 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1387 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1388 const char *name = "";
1390 bfd_boolean stringp;
1391 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1393 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1395 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1402 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1403 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1405 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1407 sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1412 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1413 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1414 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1415 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1416 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1417 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1418 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1419 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1420 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1421 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1422 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1423 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1424 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1425 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1426 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1427 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1428 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1429 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1430 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1431 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1432 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1433 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1434 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1435 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1436 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1437 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1438 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1439 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1440 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1441 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1442 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1443 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1444 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1445 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1446 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1447 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1448 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1449 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1450 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1451 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1452 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1453 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1454 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1455 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1456 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1457 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1458 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1459 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1460 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1461 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1462 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1463 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1464 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1465 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1466 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1467 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1468 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1469 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1472 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1476 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1481 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1483 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1486 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1495 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1496 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1498 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1502 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1504 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1506 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1507 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1509 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1510 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1511 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1512 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1514 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1517 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1521 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1527 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1529 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1531 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1532 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1534 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1536 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1537 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1538 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1539 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1540 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1541 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1553 /* Get version string. */
1556 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1557 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1559 const char *version_string = NULL;
1560 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1561 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1563 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1565 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1566 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1569 version_string = "";
1570 else if (vernum == 1)
1571 version_string = "Base";
1572 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1574 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1577 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1579 version_string = "";
1580 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1584 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1586 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1588 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1590 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1597 return version_string;
1600 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1603 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1606 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1608 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1611 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1612 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1614 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1615 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1616 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1617 fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
1619 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1621 const char *section_name;
1622 const char *name = NULL;
1623 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1624 unsigned char st_other;
1626 const char *version_string;
1629 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1631 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1632 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1633 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1637 name = symbol->name;
1638 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1641 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1642 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1643 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1644 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1645 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1646 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1647 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1649 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1650 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1652 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1653 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1659 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1664 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1665 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1670 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1671 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1676 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1677 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1678 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1680 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1682 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1685 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1691 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1693 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1696 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1698 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1699 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1700 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1702 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
1703 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
1704 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
1705 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
1707 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1712 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
1713 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
1714 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
1715 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
1716 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
1717 can expect to recurse at least once.
1719 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
1720 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
1722 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
1723 sections_being_created = NULL;
1724 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
1726 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
1727 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
1728 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
1729 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
1731 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
1733 (*_bfd_error_handler)
1734 (_("%B: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
1737 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
1740 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1741 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1742 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
1747 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1748 switch (hdr->sh_type)
1751 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
1754 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
1755 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
1756 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
1757 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
1758 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
1759 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
1760 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
1761 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
1762 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
1763 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1766 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
1767 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1770 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
1772 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
1773 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
1774 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
1777 case bfd_arch_sparc:
1778 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
1779 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
1781 /* Otherwise fall through. */
1786 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
1788 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
1790 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
1792 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
1793 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
1794 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
1795 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1797 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
1798 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1802 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1804 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1805 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1807 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1808 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1810 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1818 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
1819 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1822 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1825 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1827 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1829 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
1830 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
1831 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
1836 BFD_ASSERT (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0);
1837 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1838 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr = *hdr;
1839 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1840 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1842 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
1843 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
1844 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
1845 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
1846 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
1848 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
1849 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
1850 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1854 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
1855 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
1856 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
1857 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]->sh_link != shindex)
1859 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1861 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1862 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1864 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1865 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1866 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1870 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
1872 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1873 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1874 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1878 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
1882 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
1883 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1886 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1889 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1891 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1894 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
1895 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
1896 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
1901 BFD_ASSERT (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0);
1902 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1903 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
1904 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
1905 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1907 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
1908 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
1909 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1912 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
1913 if (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == shindex)
1916 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == 0);
1917 elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = shindex;
1918 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr = *hdr;
1919 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
1922 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
1923 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1926 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
1928 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1929 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
1933 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1936 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
1937 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
1941 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1944 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1945 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
1946 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
1947 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
1949 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1954 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
1955 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
1956 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
1957 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
1959 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1961 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1962 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1964 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1965 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1967 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
1970 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
1972 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
1974 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
1975 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
1979 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1984 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
1986 asection *target_sect;
1987 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
1988 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1989 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
1993 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
1994 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
1997 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
1998 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2000 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
2001 (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2002 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
2003 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2008 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2009 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2010 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2011 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2012 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2013 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2014 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2016 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2017 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2018 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2019 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2025 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2027 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2028 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2039 hdr->sh_link = found;
2042 /* Get the symbol table. */
2043 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2044 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2045 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2048 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2049 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2050 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2051 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2052 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2053 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2054 sh_link points to the null section. */
2055 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2056 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2057 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2058 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2059 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2060 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2062 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2067 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2070 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2071 if (target_sect == NULL)
2074 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2075 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2076 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2078 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2080 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2083 amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
2084 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2089 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2090 target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
2091 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2092 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2093 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2094 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2095 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2096 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2098 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2099 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2101 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2105 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2106 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2107 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2108 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2111 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2112 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2115 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2116 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2117 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2120 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2121 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2122 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2123 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2130 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2133 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2136 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
2138 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
2139 unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / sizeof (* idx);
2144 if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
2145 hdr->bfd_section->flags
2146 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
2148 /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in. */
2151 while (--n_elt != 0)
2155 if (idx->shdr != NULL
2156 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
2157 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
2159 elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
2167 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2168 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2169 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2171 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2173 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2177 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2178 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2181 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2183 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2184 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2185 for applications? */
2186 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2187 (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
2188 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2189 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2192 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2193 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2198 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2199 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2200 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2201 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2202 (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
2204 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2205 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2207 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2208 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2209 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2210 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2211 be rejected with an error message. */
2212 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2213 (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
2215 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2218 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2219 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2224 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2225 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2226 (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2227 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2235 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2236 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2237 if (-- nesting == 0)
2239 sections_being_created = NULL;
2240 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2245 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2248 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2250 unsigned long r_symndx)
2252 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2254 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2256 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2257 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2258 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2260 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2261 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2262 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2265 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2267 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2270 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2273 return &cache->sym[ent];
2276 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2280 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2282 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2284 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2287 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2289 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2290 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2293 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2295 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2296 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2299 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2301 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2302 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2303 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2304 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2305 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2306 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2307 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2308 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2309 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2310 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2311 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2312 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2313 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2314 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2317 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2319 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2320 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2321 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2324 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2326 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2327 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2328 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2329 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2330 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2331 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2332 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2333 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2334 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2335 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2338 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2340 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2341 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2344 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2346 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2347 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2348 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2349 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2352 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2354 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2355 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2358 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2360 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2361 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2362 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2365 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2367 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2368 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2369 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2372 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2374 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2375 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2376 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2377 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2378 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2381 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2383 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2384 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2385 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2386 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2387 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2388 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2389 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2392 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2394 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2395 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2396 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2397 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2400 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2402 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2403 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2404 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2405 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2406 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2409 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2411 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2412 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2413 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2415 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2416 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2417 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2418 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2421 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2423 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2425 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2427 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2428 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2429 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2435 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2438 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2439 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2440 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2446 len = strlen (name);
2448 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2451 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2453 if (len < prefix_len)
2455 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2458 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2459 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2461 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2463 if (suffix_len == 0)
2465 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2466 && (suffix_len == -2
2467 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2473 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2475 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2476 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2486 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2487 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2490 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2491 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2494 if (sec->name == NULL)
2497 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2498 spec = bed->special_sections;
2501 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2502 bed->special_sections,
2508 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2511 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2512 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2515 spec = special_sections[i];
2520 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2524 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2526 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2527 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2528 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2530 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2533 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2537 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2540 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2541 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2542 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2544 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2545 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2546 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2547 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2548 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2549 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2550 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2551 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2552 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2553 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2554 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2556 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2559 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2560 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2561 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2563 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2564 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2568 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2571 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2573 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2574 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2575 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2576 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2578 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2579 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2580 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2581 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2582 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2583 of combined data+bss.
2585 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2586 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2587 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2588 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2589 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2594 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2595 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2597 const char *type_name)
2605 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2606 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2607 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2609 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2611 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2612 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2613 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2616 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2617 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2618 if (newsect == NULL)
2620 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2621 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2622 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2623 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2624 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2625 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2626 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2628 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2629 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2630 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2632 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2634 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2637 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2639 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2643 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2647 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2648 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2649 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2652 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2653 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2654 if (newsect == NULL)
2656 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2657 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2658 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2659 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2660 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2661 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2662 align = hdr->p_align;
2663 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2664 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2666 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2667 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2668 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2669 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2670 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2671 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2672 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2674 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2675 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2676 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2678 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2679 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2686 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2688 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2690 switch (hdr->p_type)
2693 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2696 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2699 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2702 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2705 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2707 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2712 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2715 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
2717 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
2718 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
2722 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
2725 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
2728 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
2729 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2730 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
2734 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
2738 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
2740 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
2742 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
2743 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
2746 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
2750 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
2751 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
2752 const char *sec_name,
2753 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
2755 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
2756 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
2760 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
2762 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
2764 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2770 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
2771 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
2772 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
2776 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
2777 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
2778 const char *sec_name,
2779 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
2780 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
2782 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
2783 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2786 amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
2787 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
2788 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2789 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
2791 if (delay_st_name_p)
2792 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
2793 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
2796 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
2797 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
2798 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
2799 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
2800 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
2801 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
2802 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2803 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2804 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2809 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
2812 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
2814 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2815 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
2817 return SHT_PROGBITS;
2820 struct fake_section_arg
2822 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
2826 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
2829 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
2831 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
2832 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2833 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
2834 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
2835 unsigned int sh_type;
2836 const char *name = asect->name;
2837 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
2841 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
2846 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
2850 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
2851 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
2852 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
2856 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
2858 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
2860 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding setion
2861 name to section name section after it is compressed in
2862 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
2863 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
2866 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
2868 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
2869 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
2871 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
2872 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
2876 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
2877 if (new_name == NULL)
2885 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
2887 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
2888 section smaller. So only rename the section when
2889 compression has actually taken place. If input section
2890 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
2891 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
2892 if (new_name == NULL)
2897 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
2902 if (delay_st_name_p)
2903 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
2907 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2909 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2916 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
2918 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2919 || asect->user_set_vma)
2920 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
2922 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2924 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2925 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
2926 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
2927 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
2928 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
2930 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2931 (_("%B: error: Alignment power %d of section `%A' is too big"),
2932 abfd, asect, asect->alignment_power);
2936 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
2937 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
2938 copy_private_section_data. */
2940 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
2941 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
2943 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
2945 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
2946 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
2948 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
2950 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
2951 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2952 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
2953 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
2954 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2956 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
2957 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
2958 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
2959 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
2960 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2961 (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
2962 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2965 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
2971 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
2972 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
2973 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
2980 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
2984 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
2988 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
2992 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
2993 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
2997 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
2998 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3001 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3002 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3005 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3006 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3007 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3008 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3010 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3011 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3013 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3014 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3017 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3018 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3019 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3020 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3022 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3023 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3025 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3026 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3030 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3034 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3038 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3039 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3040 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3041 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3042 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3043 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3044 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3046 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3047 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3048 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3049 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3051 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3052 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3053 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3055 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3056 if (asect->size == 0
3057 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3059 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3061 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3064 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3065 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3066 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3070 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3071 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3073 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3074 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3075 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3076 create the other. */
3077 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3079 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3082 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3083 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3084 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3085 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3087 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3088 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name, FALSE,
3094 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3095 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name, TRUE,
3102 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3104 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3111 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3112 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3113 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3114 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3117 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3119 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3120 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3121 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3125 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3126 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3127 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3128 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3131 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3133 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3134 asection *elt, *first;
3138 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3140 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3144 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3146 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3148 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3150 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3151 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3155 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3156 elf_section_syms. */
3157 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3158 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3160 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3162 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3164 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3165 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3166 set until all local symbols are output. */
3167 asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3168 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3169 unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3170 unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
3171 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3173 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3175 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3177 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3178 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3180 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3181 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3182 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3183 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3185 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3188 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3190 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3193 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3195 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3196 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3197 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3204 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3206 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3207 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3208 start of the input section group. */
3209 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3211 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3212 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3213 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3214 directives, not that it matters. */
3221 s = s->output_section;
3223 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3225 unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3228 H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
3230 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3235 if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
3238 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3241 /* Return the section which RELOC_SEC applies to. */
3244 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3250 if (reloc_sec == NULL)
3253 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3254 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3257 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3258 name = reloc_sec->name;
3259 if (type == SHT_REL)
3264 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3265 section apply to .got.plt section. */
3266 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3267 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3268 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3270 /* .got.plt is a linker created input section. It may be mapped
3271 to some other output section. Try two likely sections. */
3273 reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3274 if (reloc_sec != NULL)
3279 reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3283 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3284 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3285 in here too, while we're at it. */
3288 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3290 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3292 unsigned int section_number;
3293 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3294 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3295 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3299 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3301 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3302 if (link_info == NULL || bfd_link_relocatable (link_info))
3304 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3305 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3307 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3309 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3311 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3313 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3314 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3315 abfd->section_count--;
3318 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3323 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3325 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3327 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3328 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3329 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3330 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3333 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3334 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3335 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3342 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3343 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3344 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3350 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3351 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3352 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3354 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3355 || (link_info == NULL
3356 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3360 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3361 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3362 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3364 elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = section_number++;
3365 t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name
3366 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3367 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3368 if (t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3371 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3372 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3375 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3377 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
3378 abfd, section_number);
3382 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3383 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3385 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3387 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3388 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3389 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3392 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3393 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3394 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3396 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3400 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3402 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3405 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3406 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3408 i_shdrp[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)] = &t->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3409 t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3411 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3412 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3415 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3419 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3421 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3422 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3423 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3424 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3425 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3427 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3429 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3430 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3431 the relocation entries apply. */
3432 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3434 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3435 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3436 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3438 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3440 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3441 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3442 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3445 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3446 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3448 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3451 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3452 if (link_info != NULL)
3454 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3455 if (discarded_section (s))
3458 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3459 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3460 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3462 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3463 size as the discarded one. */
3464 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3467 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3473 s = s->output_section;
3474 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3478 /* Handle objcopy. */
3479 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3481 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3482 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3483 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3484 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3487 s = s->output_section;
3489 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3494 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3495 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3496 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3498 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3499 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3500 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3501 bed->link_order_error_handler
3502 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3507 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3511 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3512 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3513 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3514 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3515 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3516 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3517 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3519 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3521 s = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->get_reloc_section (sec);
3524 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3525 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3530 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3531 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3532 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3533 field to point to this section. */
3534 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3535 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3540 len = strlen (sec->name);
3541 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3544 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3545 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3546 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3550 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3552 /* This is a .stab section. */
3553 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3554 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3555 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3562 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3563 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3564 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3565 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3567 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3569 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3572 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3573 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3574 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3575 the version strings. */
3576 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3577 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3579 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3584 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3585 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3586 this hash table or version table is for. */
3587 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3589 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3593 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3597 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3598 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3599 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3605 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3607 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3608 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3609 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3610 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3612 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3613 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3614 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3617 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3618 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
3621 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3623 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
3625 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
3628 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
3629 return ((type_ptr != NULL
3630 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
3631 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3632 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
3633 || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
3634 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
3635 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
3638 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3639 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
3642 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
3644 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3645 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3646 asymbol **sect_syms;
3647 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
3648 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
3649 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
3650 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
3657 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
3661 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3663 if (max_index < asect->index)
3664 max_index = asect->index;
3668 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
3669 if (sect_syms == NULL)
3671 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
3672 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
3674 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
3675 decided to output. */
3676 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3678 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3680 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3682 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
3683 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3685 asection *sec = sym->section;
3687 if (sec->owner != abfd)
3688 sec = sec->output_section;
3690 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
3694 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
3695 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3697 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
3699 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
3703 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
3704 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
3705 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
3706 at least in that case. */
3707 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3709 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3711 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
3718 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
3719 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
3720 sizeof (asymbol *));
3722 if (new_syms == NULL)
3725 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3727 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3730 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3731 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3732 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3737 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3739 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3741 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3743 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
3746 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
3747 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3750 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3752 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3756 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
3758 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
3762 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
3763 ELF data structure. */
3765 static inline file_ptr
3766 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
3768 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
3771 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
3772 required section alignment. */
3775 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
3779 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
3780 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
3781 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
3782 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
3783 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
3784 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
3785 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
3789 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
3790 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
3791 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
3794 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
3795 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3797 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3798 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
3800 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
3801 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
3802 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3804 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
3807 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
3808 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
3809 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
3811 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
3814 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
3815 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
3817 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
3818 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
3819 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
3823 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
3826 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
3827 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
3828 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3829 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3833 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
3834 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
3836 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
3841 if (link_info == NULL)
3843 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
3848 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
3849 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
3850 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
3851 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3852 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3853 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3854 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3855 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3856 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
3857 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3858 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
3860 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
3866 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
3868 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
3870 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
3871 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3873 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3874 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
3875 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3877 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
3878 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3880 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
3882 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
3884 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
3885 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
3887 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
3890 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
3895 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
3896 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
3898 static bfd_size_type
3899 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3903 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3905 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
3906 and one for data. */
3909 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3910 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3912 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
3913 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
3914 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
3919 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
3921 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
3925 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
3927 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
3931 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
3933 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
3937 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
3939 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
3943 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3945 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3946 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
3948 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
3950 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
3951 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
3952 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
3953 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
3954 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
3955 so we check whether the sections are correctly
3957 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
3958 while (s->next != NULL
3959 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
3960 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3961 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
3966 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3968 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3970 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
3976 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
3977 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3978 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
3982 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
3988 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
3991 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
3994 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
3996 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3997 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
3999 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4005 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4006 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4013 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4015 static struct elf_segment_map *
4016 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4017 asection **sections,
4022 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4027 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4028 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4029 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4033 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4034 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4035 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4036 m->count = to - from;
4038 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4040 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4041 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4042 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4048 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4051 struct elf_segment_map *
4052 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4054 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4056 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4057 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4061 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4063 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4068 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4071 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4072 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4073 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4075 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4076 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4078 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4079 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4080 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4081 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4083 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4086 unsigned int i, new_count;
4088 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4090 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4091 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4092 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4094 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4098 (*m)->count = new_count;
4100 if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
4106 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4107 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4109 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4116 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4119 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4122 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4123 asection **sections = NULL;
4124 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4125 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4127 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4130 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4132 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4136 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4137 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4140 unsigned int phdr_index;
4141 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4143 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4144 bfd_boolean writable;
4146 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4147 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4149 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4151 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4153 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4154 sizeof (asection *));
4155 if (sections == NULL)
4158 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4159 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4161 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4162 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4165 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4167 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4171 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4172 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4173 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4176 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4179 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4181 /* Build the mapping. */
4186 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4187 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4189 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4190 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4192 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4193 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4197 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4198 /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not. */
4199 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
4200 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4201 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4206 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4207 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4211 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4219 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4220 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4221 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4225 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4226 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4227 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4228 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4229 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4232 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4234 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4237 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4238 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4239 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4240 program headers we will need. */
4243 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4245 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4246 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4247 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4248 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4249 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4250 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4251 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4252 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4253 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4256 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4259 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4263 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4266 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4268 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4269 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4270 new_segment = FALSE;
4272 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4274 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4275 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4279 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4280 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4282 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4283 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4286 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4287 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4288 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4289 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4290 section can be included in the current segment. */
4291 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4293 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4296 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4297 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4300 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4301 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0
4302 && ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4303 || (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4304 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize))))
4306 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4307 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4308 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4309 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose.
4310 However, like the writable/non-writable case below,
4311 if they are on the same page then they must be put
4312 in the same segment. */
4315 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4317 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4318 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4319 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4320 new_segment = FALSE;
4323 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
4324 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4325 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4327 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4328 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
4329 anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
4330 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
4331 only case in which the new section is not on the same
4332 page as the previous section is when the previous section
4333 ends precisely on a page boundary. */
4338 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4339 new_segment = FALSE;
4342 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4343 if (last_hdr != NULL
4345 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4347 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4353 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4356 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4357 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4358 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4359 last_size = hdr->size;
4365 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4366 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4368 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4375 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4381 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4382 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4383 last_size = hdr->size;
4387 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4390 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4392 if (last_hdr != NULL
4393 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4394 || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4395 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
4397 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4405 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4408 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4415 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4416 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4417 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4418 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4419 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4421 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4423 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4424 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4429 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4430 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4431 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4433 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4434 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4435 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4436 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4442 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4443 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4447 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4451 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4452 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4455 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4456 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4460 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4468 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4471 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4472 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4473 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4478 m->count = tls_count;
4479 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4481 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4483 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4485 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4488 (_("%B: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4491 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4493 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4495 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %A"), s);
4499 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %A"), s);
4502 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4513 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4515 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
4516 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4517 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4519 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4520 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4524 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4526 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4532 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4534 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4535 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4539 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4540 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
4541 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
4542 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4543 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
4544 if (info->stacksize > 0)
4546 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
4547 m->p_size_valid = 1;
4554 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4556 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4558 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
4560 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
4561 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
4564 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
4565 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4566 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4569 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
4574 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
4577 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4578 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4582 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
4584 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4592 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
4595 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
4598 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4600 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4605 if (sections != NULL)
4610 /* Sort sections by address. */
4613 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
4615 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
4616 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
4617 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
4619 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
4620 place the section into a segment. */
4621 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
4623 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
4626 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
4627 the same, and this will do nothing. */
4628 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
4630 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
4633 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
4635 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
4641 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
4642 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
4643 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
4644 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4649 else if (TOEND (sec2))
4654 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
4655 before others at the same address. */
4657 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
4658 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
4665 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4668 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
4670 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
4671 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
4672 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
4673 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
4674 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
4677 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
4678 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
4680 /* In other words, something like:
4682 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
4683 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
4684 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
4685 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
4687 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
4689 which can can be collapsed into the expression below. */
4692 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
4694 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
4695 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4697 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
4701 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
4704 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
4709 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
4710 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
4711 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
4712 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
4713 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
4714 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
4716 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
4717 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
4721 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
4722 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
4723 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
4729 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
4734 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
4736 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
4739 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
4744 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
4745 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
4749 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4750 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4752 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4753 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4754 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4755 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4757 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
4760 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
4762 if (link_info == NULL
4763 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
4767 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4771 header_pad = m->header_size;
4776 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4777 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4781 /* PR binutils/12467. */
4782 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
4783 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
4786 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
4788 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4789 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4791 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
4792 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
4796 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4800 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
4801 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
4802 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
4803 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
4804 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
4806 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
4807 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
4808 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
4809 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
4811 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
4813 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
4814 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
4815 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
4820 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4821 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4823 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4824 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4825 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
4831 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
4833 m = m->next, p++, j++)
4837 bfd_boolean no_contents;
4839 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
4840 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
4841 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
4842 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
4843 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
4845 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
4846 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
4847 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
4850 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
4851 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
4852 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
4853 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
4854 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
4855 p->p_type = m->p_type;
4856 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
4861 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4863 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
4864 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
4865 else if (m->count == 0)
4868 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4870 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4871 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4873 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
4874 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
4875 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
4876 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
4877 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
4878 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
4879 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
4881 if (m->p_align_valid)
4882 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
4884 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
4886 else if (m->p_align_valid)
4887 p->p_align = m->p_align;
4888 else if (m->count == 0)
4889 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
4893 no_contents = FALSE;
4895 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4898 bfd_size_type align;
4899 unsigned int align_power = 0;
4901 if (m->p_align_valid)
4905 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4907 unsigned int secalign;
4909 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
4910 if (secalign > align_power)
4911 align_power = secalign;
4913 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
4914 if (align < maxpagesize)
4915 align = maxpagesize;
4918 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4919 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
4920 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
4921 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
4922 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
4923 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
4925 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
4928 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4929 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
4931 no_contents = FALSE;
4935 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
4939 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
4940 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
4941 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
4942 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
4943 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
4944 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
4945 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
4946 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
4951 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
4952 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4953 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
4955 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
4958 (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
4960 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4963 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
4964 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
4965 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4966 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
4972 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4974 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4976 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4977 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4980 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
4982 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4983 (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
4985 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4990 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4995 if (m->includes_phdrs)
4997 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5000 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5002 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5006 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5007 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5008 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5012 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5013 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5016 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5017 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5021 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5022 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5024 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5030 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5032 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5033 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5037 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5038 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5039 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5040 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5041 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5042 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5045 bfd_size_type align;
5046 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5049 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5050 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5052 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5053 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5054 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5055 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5056 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5057 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5059 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5060 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5061 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5062 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5066 || p_end < p_start))
5068 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5069 (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
5070 (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
5074 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5076 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5078 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5080 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5081 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5083 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5084 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5088 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5092 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5094 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5098 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5099 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5100 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5106 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5115 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5117 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5118 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5119 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5121 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5122 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5123 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5125 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5126 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5127 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5128 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5129 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5130 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5132 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5134 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5137 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5139 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5140 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5141 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5142 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5143 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5144 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5146 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5148 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5149 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5151 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5153 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5154 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5157 if (align > p->p_align
5158 && !m->p_align_valid
5159 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5160 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5164 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5167 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5169 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5176 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5177 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5178 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5180 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5182 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5183 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5184 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5185 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5186 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5187 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5189 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5194 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5196 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5199 sec = m->sections[i];
5200 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5201 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5202 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5204 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5205 (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5207 print_segment_map (m);
5213 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5217 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5220 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5221 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5223 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5224 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5225 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5226 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5227 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5228 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5229 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5230 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5231 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5235 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5236 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5237 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5238 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5240 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5243 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5244 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5245 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5246 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5247 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5248 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5250 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5251 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5252 (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5254 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5256 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5257 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5258 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5259 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5262 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5264 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5267 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5268 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5269 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5270 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5271 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5272 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5273 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]
5274 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5275 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5276 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5278 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5281 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5282 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5286 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5288 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5289 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5290 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5293 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5296 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5298 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5299 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5301 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5303 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5304 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5305 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5308 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5309 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5314 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5316 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5317 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5318 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5320 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5321 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5322 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5323 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5325 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5326 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5327 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5328 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5331 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5332 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5333 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5335 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5336 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5345 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5346 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5350 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5351 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5354 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5355 hash->def_regular = 1;
5360 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5362 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5364 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5365 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5367 if (link_info != NULL)
5369 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5371 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5373 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5375 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5376 && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
5378 && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
5382 BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
5386 /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
5387 library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
5388 for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
5390 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5391 && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
5396 if (lp < phdrs + count)
5398 p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
5399 p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
5400 p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
5401 if (link_info != NULL)
5402 p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
5403 else if (m->p_size_valid)
5404 p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
5407 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
5408 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
5409 gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
5410 It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5411 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
5413 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5415 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5416 p->p_flags = (lp->p_flags & ~PF_W);
5420 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5421 p->p_type = PT_NULL;
5424 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5426 if (m->p_size_valid)
5427 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5429 else if (m->count != 0)
5432 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5433 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5434 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5436 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
5438 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
5439 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5440 (_("%B: warning: non-load segment includes file header and/or program header"),
5446 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5447 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5449 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5450 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
5451 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5453 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
5460 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
5462 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
5463 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5464 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
5466 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
5468 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
5469 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5470 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
5474 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5479 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
5480 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
5481 VMAs must be known before this is called.
5483 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
5484 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
5485 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
5486 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
5487 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
5488 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
5489 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
5491 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
5494 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
5495 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5497 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
5498 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5499 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5501 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
5502 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5504 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5505 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5506 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
5510 /* Start after the ELF header. */
5511 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
5513 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
5514 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
5515 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
5516 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
5518 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5521 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5522 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5523 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5524 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5525 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5526 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
5527 || i == elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)
5528 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
5529 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
5531 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5534 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5537 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5543 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
5544 assignment of sections to segments. */
5545 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5548 /* And for non-load sections. */
5549 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5552 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
5554 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
5558 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
5559 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
5561 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
5562 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5563 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
5565 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
5566 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
5567 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
5568 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
5569 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5571 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
5572 segments is non-zero. */
5574 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5577 /* Write out the program headers. */
5578 alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5579 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
5580 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
5588 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
5590 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
5591 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
5592 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5594 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5596 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
5597 if (shstrtab == NULL)
5600 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
5602 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
5603 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
5604 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
5605 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
5607 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
5608 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
5609 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
5610 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
5612 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5613 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
5614 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
5615 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5616 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5617 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
5619 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
5621 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
5623 case bfd_arch_unknown:
5624 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
5627 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
5628 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
5629 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
5630 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
5631 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
5632 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
5633 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
5634 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
5636 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
5639 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
5640 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5642 /* No program header, for now. */
5643 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5644 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5645 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
5647 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
5648 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
5649 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
5651 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
5652 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
5653 /* It all happens later. */
5657 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5658 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5661 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
5662 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
5663 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
5664 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
5665 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
5666 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
5667 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5668 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5669 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
5675 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
5676 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
5679 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
5682 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
5683 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
5684 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
5685 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5687 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5689 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5690 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5691 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
5694 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
5696 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
5697 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
5698 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
5700 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
5704 const char *name = sec->name;
5705 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
5707 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5708 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
5712 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
5713 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
5715 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
5716 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
5718 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
5719 if (new_name == NULL)
5723 /* Add setion name to section name section. */
5724 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
5727 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
5729 d = elf_section_data (sec);
5731 /* Add reloc setion name to section name section. */
5733 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
5738 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
5743 /* Update section size and contents. */
5744 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
5745 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
5746 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
5748 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
5755 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
5757 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
5758 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
5759 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
5760 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
5762 /* Place the section headers. */
5763 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5764 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5765 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
5766 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
5767 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
5768 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5774 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
5776 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5777 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
5779 unsigned int count, num_sec;
5780 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
5782 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
5783 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
5786 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5789 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
5793 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
5796 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
5797 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5798 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
5800 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
5801 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
5802 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
5803 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
5804 (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
5805 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
5807 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
5809 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5810 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
5815 /* Write out the section header names. */
5816 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
5817 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
5818 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5819 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
5822 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
5823 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
5825 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
5828 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
5829 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
5830 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
5836 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
5838 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
5839 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
5842 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
5845 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
5847 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5848 unsigned int sec_index;
5850 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
5851 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
5852 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
5854 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
5855 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
5856 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
5857 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
5858 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
5859 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
5861 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
5863 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5864 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
5866 int retval = sec_index;
5868 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
5872 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
5873 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
5878 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
5882 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
5884 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
5886 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
5888 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
5889 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
5890 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
5891 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
5892 input sections rather than the output section. */
5893 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
5894 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
5895 && asym_ptr->section)
5900 sec = asym_ptr->section;
5901 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
5902 sec = sec->output_section;
5903 if (sec->owner == abfd
5904 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
5905 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
5906 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
5909 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
5913 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
5914 which is used in a relocation entry. */
5915 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5916 (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
5917 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
5918 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
5925 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
5926 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
5934 /* Rewrite program header information. */
5937 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5939 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5940 struct elf_segment_map *map;
5941 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5942 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5943 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5946 unsigned int num_segments;
5947 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
5948 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
5949 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
5950 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
5951 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
5952 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5954 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
5955 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
5958 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
5960 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5961 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
5963 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
5964 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
5965 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
5966 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
5968 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
5969 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5970 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
5971 ? section->size : 0)
5973 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5974 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
5975 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
5976 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
5977 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5978 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
5980 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5981 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
5982 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
5983 (section->lma >= base \
5984 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5985 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
5987 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
5988 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
5989 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
5990 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
5991 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5992 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5993 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5995 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
5997 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
5999 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6003 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6004 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6005 p_memsz set to 0. */
6006 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6008 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6009 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6010 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6011 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6013 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6014 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6015 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6017 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6018 A section will be included if:
6019 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6020 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6021 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6023 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6024 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6025 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6026 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6027 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6028 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6029 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6030 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6031 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6032 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6033 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6034 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6035 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6036 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6037 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6038 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6039 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6040 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6041 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6042 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6043 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6044 || (segment->p_paddr \
6045 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6046 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6047 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6049 && !section->segment_mark)
6051 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6052 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6053 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6054 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6055 && section->output_section != NULL)
6057 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6058 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6059 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6061 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6062 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6063 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6064 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6065 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6067 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6068 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6069 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6070 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6071 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6073 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6074 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6075 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6077 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6078 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6079 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6080 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6081 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6082 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6085 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6087 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6091 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6092 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6093 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6094 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6095 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6100 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6102 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6103 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6104 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6106 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6107 assignment code will work. */
6108 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6112 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6114 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6115 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6116 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6120 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6121 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6123 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6125 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6126 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6129 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6130 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6132 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6134 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6135 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6137 if (extra_length > 0)
6139 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6140 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6143 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6145 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6147 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6152 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6154 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6155 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6157 if (extra_length > 0)
6159 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6160 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6163 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6168 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6169 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6173 unsigned int section_count;
6174 asection **sections;
6175 asection *output_section;
6177 bfd_vma matching_lma;
6178 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
6181 asection *first_section;
6182 bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
6183 bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
6185 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6188 first_section = NULL;
6189 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6190 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6192 section = section->next)
6194 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6195 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6196 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6198 if (first_section == NULL)
6199 first_section = section;
6200 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6205 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6206 all of the sections we have selected. */
6207 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6208 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6209 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6213 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6214 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6216 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6217 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6218 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6220 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6221 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6223 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6225 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6226 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6229 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6230 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6231 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6232 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6233 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6235 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6237 map->includes_phdrs =
6238 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6239 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6240 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6241 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6243 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6244 phdr_included = TRUE;
6247 if (section_count == 0)
6249 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6250 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6251 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6252 a warning is produced. */
6253 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
6254 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("\
6255 %B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected, is this intentional ?"),
6259 *pointer_to_map = map;
6260 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6265 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6266 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6267 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6268 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6270 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6271 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6274 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6275 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6276 of the first section.
6278 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6279 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6280 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6281 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6282 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6284 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6285 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6286 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6287 or segments to contain the other sections.
6289 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6290 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6291 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6293 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6294 if (sections == NULL)
6297 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6298 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6299 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6300 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6301 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6306 first_matching_lma = TRUE;
6307 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6309 for (section = ibfd->sections;
6311 section = section->next)
6312 if (section == first_section)
6315 for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6317 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6319 output_section = section->output_section;
6321 sections[j++] = section;
6323 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6324 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6325 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6326 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6328 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6329 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6331 && output_section->lma != 0
6332 && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
6333 + (map->includes_filehdr
6336 + (map->includes_phdrs
6338 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6340 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6342 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6343 LMA address of the output section. */
6344 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6345 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6346 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6347 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6349 if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
6351 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
6352 first_matching_lma = FALSE;
6355 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6356 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6358 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6360 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6362 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6363 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6366 if (j == section_count)
6371 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6373 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6375 if (isec == section_count)
6377 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6378 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6379 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6380 program header in the input BFD. */
6381 map->count = section_count;
6382 *pointer_to_map = map;
6383 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6386 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6387 && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
6388 && !map->includes_filehdr
6389 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6390 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6391 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6393 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
6400 if (!first_matching_lma)
6402 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
6403 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
6404 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
6405 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
6409 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
6410 Change the current segment's physical address to match
6411 the LMA of the first section. */
6412 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6415 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
6416 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
6417 if (map->includes_filehdr)
6419 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
6420 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
6423 map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
6424 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6428 if (map->includes_phdrs)
6430 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6432 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6434 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
6435 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
6436 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
6437 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
6438 offset when we know the correct value. */
6439 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
6440 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
6443 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6447 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
6448 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
6449 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
6450 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
6451 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
6452 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
6459 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6461 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
6462 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
6464 section = sections[j];
6466 if (section == NULL)
6469 output_section = section->output_section;
6471 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
6473 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6474 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
6476 if (map->count == 0)
6478 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
6479 the beginning of the segment, then something is
6481 if (output_section->lma
6483 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6484 + (map->includes_phdrs
6485 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6493 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
6495 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
6496 and the start of this section is more than
6497 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
6498 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
6500 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
6501 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
6502 > output_section->lma))
6504 if (first_suggested_lma)
6506 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6507 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6514 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
6517 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
6519 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6521 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6522 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6526 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
6528 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
6529 *pointer_to_map = map;
6530 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6532 if (isec < section_count)
6534 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
6535 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
6536 and carry on looping. */
6537 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6538 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6539 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6546 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
6547 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
6548 not yet been assigned. */
6550 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6551 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6552 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6553 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6554 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6555 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
6556 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6559 while (isec < section_count);
6564 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
6566 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
6567 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
6568 the offset if necessary. */
6569 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
6573 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
6576 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
6577 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
6578 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6583 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
6584 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
6586 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
6587 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
6588 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
6589 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
6590 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
6591 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
6595 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
6598 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6600 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6601 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6602 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6603 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6604 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6606 unsigned int num_segments;
6607 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6608 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6610 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6613 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6615 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
6616 map->p_paddr_valid. */
6617 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6618 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6619 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6622 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6624 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6628 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6633 unsigned int section_count;
6635 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6636 asection *first_section = NULL;
6637 asection *lowest_section;
6639 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
6640 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6642 section = section->next)
6644 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6645 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6647 if (first_section == NULL)
6648 first_section = section;
6653 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6654 all of the sections we have selected. */
6655 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6656 if (section_count != 0)
6657 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6658 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6662 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
6665 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6666 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6667 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6668 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6669 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6670 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
6671 map->p_align_valid = 1;
6672 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
6674 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
6675 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6677 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
6678 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
6679 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
6680 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
6681 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
6683 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
6684 map->p_size_valid = 1;
6687 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6688 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6689 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6690 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6692 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6693 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6695 map->includes_phdrs =
6696 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6697 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6698 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6699 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6701 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6702 phdr_included = TRUE;
6705 lowest_section = NULL;
6706 if (section_count != 0)
6708 unsigned int isec = 0;
6710 for (section = first_section;
6712 section = section->next)
6714 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6715 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6717 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
6718 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6722 if (lowest_section == NULL
6723 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
6724 lowest_section = section;
6726 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
6727 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
6728 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
6729 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
6731 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
6732 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
6734 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
6735 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
6736 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6738 if (isec == section_count)
6744 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
6745 /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
6746 map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
6748 if (!map->includes_phdrs
6749 && !map->includes_filehdr
6750 && map->p_paddr_valid)
6751 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
6752 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
6753 - segment->p_paddr);
6755 map->count = section_count;
6756 *pointer_to_map = map;
6757 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6760 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
6764 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
6768 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6770 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6771 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6774 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
6777 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6779 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
6780 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
6781 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6782 asection *section, *osec;
6783 unsigned int i, num_segments;
6784 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6785 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6787 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6789 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
6790 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
6793 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
6794 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6795 section = section->next)
6796 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6798 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6799 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6803 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
6804 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
6805 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
6806 map in this case. */
6807 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
6808 && segment->p_memsz == 0
6809 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
6812 for (section = ibfd->sections;
6813 section != NULL; section = section->next)
6815 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
6816 from the input BFD. */
6817 osec = section->output_section;
6819 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
6821 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
6822 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6823 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6825 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
6826 removed. What else do we need to check? */
6828 || section->flags != osec->flags
6829 || section->lma != osec->lma
6830 || section->vma != osec->vma
6831 || section->size != osec->size
6832 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
6833 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
6839 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
6841 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6842 section = section->next)
6844 if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
6847 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6850 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6854 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6856 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
6857 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
6858 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6860 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6861 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
6863 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6866 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6867 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
6869 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
6870 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
6871 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("\
6872 %B: warning: segment alignment of 0x%llx is too large"),
6873 ibfd, (long long) segment->p_align);
6875 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
6878 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
6879 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
6882 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6885 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
6888 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6892 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6895 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6896 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
6897 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
6899 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6900 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6903 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
6905 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
6906 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
6907 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
6908 that the linker clears to differ. */
6909 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
6910 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
6912 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
6913 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
6914 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
6916 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
6917 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6918 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
6920 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
6921 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
6922 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
6923 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
6926 if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
6927 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6929 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
6930 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
6931 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6932 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
6935 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
6936 if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
6937 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6941 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6943 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
6944 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
6945 may be NULL at this point. */
6946 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
6948 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6949 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
6950 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
6953 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
6958 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
6959 field, and sometimes the info field. */
6962 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6967 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6969 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6970 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6973 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6974 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6976 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
6978 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
6979 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
6980 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
6981 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
6982 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
6984 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
6988 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
6989 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
6990 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
6991 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
6992 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
6996 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7000 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7001 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7003 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7004 asection *s = first;
7005 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7009 /* If this member section is being output but the
7010 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7011 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7012 if (s->output_section != discarded
7013 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7015 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7016 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7018 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7019 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7020 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7021 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7023 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7029 if (discarded != NULL)
7031 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7032 adjust the input section size. This function may
7033 be called multiple times, so save the original
7035 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7036 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7037 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7041 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7043 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7051 /* Copy private header information. */
7054 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7056 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7057 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7060 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7061 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7062 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7063 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7064 already been worked out. */
7065 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7067 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7071 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7074 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7075 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7076 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7077 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7078 swap_out_syms function. */
7080 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7081 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7082 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7083 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7084 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7087 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7092 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7094 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7095 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7098 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7099 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7102 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7104 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7108 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7109 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7110 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7111 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7112 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7113 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7115 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7116 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7117 else if (shndx == elf_symtab_shndx (ibfd))
7118 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7119 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7125 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7128 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7129 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7132 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7135 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7136 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7137 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7138 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7139 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7140 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7141 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7142 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7143 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7145 unsigned int num_locals;
7147 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7149 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7152 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7153 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7157 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7158 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7159 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7160 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7161 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7162 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7163 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7164 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7166 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7167 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7169 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7170 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7171 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7172 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7174 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7178 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7179 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7180 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7183 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7187 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7188 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7190 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7191 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7192 symtab_shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
7193 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7195 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7196 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7197 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7198 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7201 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7202 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7203 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7204 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7205 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7208 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7210 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7211 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7217 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7218 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7219 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7220 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7221 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7222 outbound_syms_index++;
7223 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7224 outbound_shndx_index++;
7228 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7229 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7231 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7232 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7234 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7235 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7236 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7237 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7240 if (!name_local_sections
7241 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7243 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7244 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7248 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7249 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7251 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7253 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7257 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7259 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7260 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7262 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7263 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7264 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7265 sym.st_size = value;
7266 if (type_ptr == NULL
7267 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7268 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7270 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7271 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7272 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7276 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7279 if (sec->output_section)
7281 value += sec->output_offset;
7282 sec = sec->output_section;
7285 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7286 if (! relocatable_p)
7288 sym.st_value = value;
7289 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7291 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7293 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7295 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7296 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7297 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7298 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7302 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7305 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7308 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7311 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7314 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx (abfd);
7323 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7325 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7329 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7330 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7331 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7332 demand of applications. For example, it
7333 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7334 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7335 actually in the output file. */
7336 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7339 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
7340 Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7341 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7343 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7347 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7348 BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
7352 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7355 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7357 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7358 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7359 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
7361 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
7363 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
7365 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
7370 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
7373 /* Processor-specific types. */
7374 if (type_ptr != NULL
7375 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7376 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7377 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
7379 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7381 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7382 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7384 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
7386 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7388 #ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
7389 if (type == STT_OBJECT)
7390 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
7393 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
7395 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
7396 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
7400 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
7401 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
7404 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
7406 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
7408 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
7409 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
7410 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
7412 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7415 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
7418 if (type_ptr != NULL)
7420 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
7421 sym.st_target_internal
7422 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
7427 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7431 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
7432 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7433 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7435 outbound_syms_index++;
7436 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7437 outbound_shndx_index++;
7440 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
7441 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
7443 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
7444 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
7446 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
7447 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7448 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
7450 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
7451 elfsym->sym.st_name);
7452 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
7454 + (elfsym->dest_index
7455 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
7457 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
7458 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
7463 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
7464 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7466 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
7467 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
7468 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7469 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
7470 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
7471 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
7476 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
7478 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
7479 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
7480 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
7483 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7487 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7489 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
7490 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
7492 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
7498 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7502 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
7504 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7506 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7510 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
7511 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
7513 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
7519 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7522 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
7525 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
7528 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
7535 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7537 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
7540 tblptr = section->relocation;
7541 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
7542 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
7546 return section->reloc_count;
7550 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
7552 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7553 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
7556 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
7561 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
7562 asymbol **allocation)
7564 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7565 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
7568 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
7572 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
7573 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
7574 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
7575 dynamic reloc section. */
7578 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7583 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7585 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7589 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
7590 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7591 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
7592 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
7593 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
7594 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
7595 * sizeof (arelent *));
7600 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
7601 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
7602 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
7603 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
7604 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
7605 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
7606 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
7609 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
7613 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
7617 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7619 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7623 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
7625 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7627 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
7628 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
7629 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
7634 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
7636 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
7638 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
7649 /* Read in the version information. */
7652 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
7654 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
7655 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
7657 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
7659 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7660 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
7661 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
7663 bfd_byte *contents_end;
7665 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
7667 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
7669 error_return_bad_verref:
7670 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7671 (_("%B: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
7672 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7673 error_return_verref:
7674 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
7675 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
7679 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7680 if (contents == NULL)
7681 goto error_return_verref;
7683 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7684 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7685 goto error_return_verref;
7687 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
7688 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
7690 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
7691 goto error_return_verref;
7693 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
7694 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
7695 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
7696 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
7697 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
7698 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
7700 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
7701 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
7704 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
7706 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
7708 iverneed->vn_filename =
7709 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7711 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
7712 goto error_return_bad_verref;
7714 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
7715 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
7718 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
7719 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
7720 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
7721 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
7722 goto error_return_verref;
7725 if (iverneed->vn_aux
7726 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7727 goto error_return_bad_verref;
7729 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7730 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
7731 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
7732 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
7734 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
7736 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
7737 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7738 ivernaux->vna_name);
7739 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
7740 goto error_return_bad_verref;
7742 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
7743 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
7745 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
7746 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
7748 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
7751 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
7752 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
7754 if (ivernaux->vna_next
7755 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
7756 goto error_return_bad_verref;
7758 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7759 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
7762 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
7763 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
7765 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
7766 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
7768 if (iverneed->vn_next
7769 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7770 goto error_return_bad_verref;
7772 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
7773 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
7775 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
7781 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
7783 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7784 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
7785 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7786 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
7787 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
7789 unsigned int maxidx;
7790 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
7792 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
7794 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
7796 error_return_bad_verdef:
7797 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7798 (_("%B: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
7799 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7800 error_return_verdef:
7801 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
7802 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
7806 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7807 if (contents == NULL)
7808 goto error_return_verdef;
7809 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7810 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7811 goto error_return_verdef;
7813 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
7814 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
7815 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
7816 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
7817 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
7818 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
7820 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
7821 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
7823 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7825 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
7827 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7829 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
7830 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7831 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
7832 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
7834 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
7837 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
7838 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7839 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7841 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7842 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
7845 if (default_imported_symver)
7847 if (freeidx > maxidx)
7853 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7854 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7855 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7856 goto error_return_verdef;
7858 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
7860 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7861 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
7862 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
7864 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
7865 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7868 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7870 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
7871 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7873 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
7874 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
7876 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7878 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
7879 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
7882 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7883 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
7884 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7885 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7886 goto error_return_verdef;
7890 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7891 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7893 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7894 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
7895 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7896 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
7898 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
7900 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
7901 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7902 iverdaux->vda_name);
7903 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
7904 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7906 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7907 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
7909 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
7912 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
7913 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
7915 if (iverdaux->vda_next
7916 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
7917 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7919 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7920 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
7923 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
7924 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
7925 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
7927 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7928 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
7930 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
7931 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
7933 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7934 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
7940 else if (default_imported_symver)
7947 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7948 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7949 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7952 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
7955 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
7956 if (default_imported_symver)
7958 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7959 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7961 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
7963 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
7964 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
7965 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
7966 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
7968 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7970 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
7971 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
7972 goto error_return_verdef;
7973 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
7974 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7975 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
7976 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7977 goto error_return_verdef;
7979 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7980 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
7986 if (contents != NULL)
7992 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
7994 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
7996 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
7999 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8000 return &newsym->symbol;
8004 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8008 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8011 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8012 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8016 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8019 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8020 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8023 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8024 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8025 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8028 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8029 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8030 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8031 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8032 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8033 we treat such symbols as local. */
8034 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8037 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8038 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8039 These labels have the form:
8041 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8043 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8045 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8046 so we only need to match the rest. */
8047 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8049 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8053 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8055 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8057 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8058 /* A fake symbol. */
8061 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8062 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8063 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8064 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8065 other than some kind of local ? */
8082 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8083 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8090 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8091 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8092 unsigned long machine)
8094 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8095 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8096 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8097 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8098 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8101 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8104 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8105 for error reporting. */
8108 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8112 const char **filename_ptr,
8113 const char **functionname_ptr,
8114 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8115 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8119 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8120 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8121 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8122 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8123 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8124 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8125 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8128 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8129 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8130 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8135 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8136 &found, filename_ptr,
8137 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8138 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8140 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8143 if (symbols == NULL)
8146 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8147 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8154 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8157 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8158 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8160 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8161 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8162 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8163 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8166 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8167 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8168 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8169 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8170 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8173 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8174 const char **filename_ptr,
8175 const char **functionname_ptr,
8176 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8179 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8180 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8181 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8186 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8188 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8189 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8191 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8193 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8195 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8197 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8200 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8201 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8204 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8207 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8215 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8217 const void *location,
8219 bfd_size_type count)
8221 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8224 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8225 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8231 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8232 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8234 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8235 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8236 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8237 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8238 || contents == NULL)
8240 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8243 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8244 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8245 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8252 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8253 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8254 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8259 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8262 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8264 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8266 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8268 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8269 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8271 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8272 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8274 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8276 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8279 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8282 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8285 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8288 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8291 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8294 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8300 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8302 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8304 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8305 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8307 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8312 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8318 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8321 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8324 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8327 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8330 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8336 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8340 areloc->howto = howto;
8348 (*_bfd_error_handler)
8349 (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
8350 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8351 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8356 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
8358 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
8359 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
8361 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
8362 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
8363 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8366 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
8369 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
8370 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
8371 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
8374 bfd_reloc_status_type
8375 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
8376 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8377 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8378 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8379 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8381 return bfd_reloc_ok;
8384 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
8385 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
8386 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
8387 out details about the corefile. */
8389 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
8390 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
8391 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
8392 # include <sys/procfs.h>
8395 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
8396 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
8399 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
8403 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
8405 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
8410 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
8411 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
8412 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
8416 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
8420 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
8423 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
8427 sect2->size = sect->size;
8428 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
8429 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
8433 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
8434 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
8435 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
8436 such a section already exists.
8437 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
8438 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
8439 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
8441 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8447 char *threaded_name;
8451 /* Build the section name. */
8453 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8454 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8455 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8456 if (threaded_name == NULL)
8458 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
8460 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
8465 sect->filepos = filepos;
8466 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8468 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
8471 /* prstatus_t exists on:
8473 linux 2.[01] + glibc
8477 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8480 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8485 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
8489 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
8490 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
8491 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
8493 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
8494 has already been set by another thread. */
8495 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8496 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
8497 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
8498 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
8500 /* pr_who exists on:
8503 pr_who doesn't exist on:
8506 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
8507 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
8509 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
8512 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
8513 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
8515 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8516 prstatus32_t prstat;
8518 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
8519 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
8520 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
8522 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
8523 has already been set by another thread. */
8524 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8525 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
8526 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
8527 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
8529 /* pr_who exists on:
8532 pr_who doesn't exist on:
8535 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
8536 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
8538 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
8541 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
8544 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8545 note size (ie. data object type). */
8549 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
8550 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
8551 size, note->descpos + offset);
8553 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
8555 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
8557 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8559 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8561 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
8562 note->descsz, note->descpos);
8565 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
8566 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
8567 data structure apart. */
8570 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8572 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8575 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
8576 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
8580 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8582 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
8585 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
8586 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
8587 contents literally. */
8590 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8592 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
8596 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8598 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
8602 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8604 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
8608 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8610 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
8614 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8616 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
8620 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8622 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
8626 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8628 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
8632 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8634 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
8638 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8640 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
8644 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8646 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
8650 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8652 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
8656 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8658 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
8662 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8664 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
8668 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8670 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
8674 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8676 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
8680 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8682 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
8686 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8688 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
8692 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8694 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
8697 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
8698 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
8699 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8700 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8704 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8705 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
8706 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8707 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8711 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
8712 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
8713 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
8716 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
8719 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
8727 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
8731 memcpy (dups, start, len);
8737 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8739 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8741 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
8743 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
8745 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8747 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
8748 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8750 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
8751 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8752 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8754 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8755 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8756 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8758 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8759 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
8761 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8762 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
8764 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8766 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
8767 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8769 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
8770 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8771 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8773 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8774 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8775 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8781 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8782 note size (ie. data object type). */
8786 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
8787 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
8788 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
8791 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
8792 int n = strlen (command);
8794 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
8795 command[n - 1] = '\0';
8800 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
8802 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8804 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8806 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
8807 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
8808 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
8814 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8816 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8818 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8819 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
8821 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8824 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8826 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8829 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
8830 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
8831 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
8835 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
8837 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8839 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8841 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8847 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
8848 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
8849 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
8854 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
8856 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
8857 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
8859 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8860 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
8862 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8864 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8865 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8866 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8869 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8871 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8875 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8876 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8877 sect->filepos = note->descpos
8878 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8881 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8882 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
8883 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
8886 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8888 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8891 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
8893 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8894 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8895 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8898 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8900 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8904 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8905 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8906 sect->filepos = note->descpos
8907 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8910 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
8911 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
8912 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
8915 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8917 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
8919 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
8922 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8929 int is_active_thread;
8932 if (note->descsz < 728)
8935 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
8938 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
8942 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
8943 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
8944 /* process_info.pid */
8945 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8946 /* process_info.signal */
8947 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
8950 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
8951 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8952 /* thread_info.tid */
8953 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
8955 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8956 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8960 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8962 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8966 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8968 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
8969 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
8970 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8972 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
8973 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
8975 if (is_active_thread)
8976 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8980 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
8981 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
8982 /* module_info.base_address */
8983 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
8984 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
8986 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8987 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8991 memcpy (name, buf, len);
8993 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8998 sect->size = note->descsz;
8999 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9000 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9011 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9013 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9021 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9022 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9024 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9025 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9030 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9032 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9035 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9037 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9040 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9041 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9043 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9044 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9046 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9047 if (note->namesz == 6
9048 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9049 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9053 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9054 if (note->namesz == 6
9055 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9056 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9057 else if (note->namesz == 8
9058 && strcmp (note->namedata, "FreeBSD") == 0)
9059 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9064 if (note->namesz == 6
9065 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9066 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9071 if (note->namesz == 6
9072 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9073 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9077 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9078 if (note->namesz == 6
9079 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9080 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9085 if (note->namesz == 6
9086 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9087 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9091 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9092 if (note->namesz == 6
9093 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9094 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9098 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9099 if (note->namesz == 6
9100 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9101 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9106 if (note->namesz == 6
9107 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9108 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9112 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9113 if (note->namesz == 6
9114 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9115 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9119 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9120 if (note->namesz == 6
9121 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9122 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9126 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9127 if (note->namesz == 6
9128 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9129 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9134 if (note->namesz == 6
9135 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9136 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9140 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9141 if (note->namesz == 6
9142 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9143 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9147 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9148 if (note->namesz == 6
9149 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9150 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9155 if (note->namesz == 6
9156 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9157 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9162 if (note->namesz == 6
9163 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9164 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9168 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9169 if (note->namesz == 6
9170 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9171 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9175 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9176 if (note->namesz == 6
9177 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9178 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9184 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9185 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9187 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9188 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9195 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9200 sect->size = note->descsz;
9201 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9202 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9208 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9212 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9218 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9220 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9222 if (note->descsz == 0)
9225 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9226 if (build_id == NULL)
9229 build_id->size = note->descsz;
9230 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9231 abfd->build_id = build_id;
9237 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9244 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9245 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9250 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9252 struct sdt_note *cur =
9253 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9256 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9257 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9258 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9260 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9266 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9271 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9279 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
9283 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
9286 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
9293 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9295 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
9296 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9297 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
9299 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
9300 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9301 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
9303 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
9304 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9305 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
9307 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
9312 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9316 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
9317 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
9319 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
9321 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
9322 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
9323 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
9324 creates a core file. */
9326 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
9329 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
9330 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
9331 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
9334 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
9338 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
9340 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
9341 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
9343 case bfd_arch_alpha:
9344 case bfd_arch_sparc:
9347 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
9348 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9350 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
9351 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9357 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
9358 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
9363 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
9364 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9366 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
9367 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9377 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9379 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
9380 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9381 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
9383 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
9384 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9385 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
9387 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
9388 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9389 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
9395 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9397 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
9398 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
9400 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
9401 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9403 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
9404 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9406 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
9407 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9409 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
9411 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9416 sect->size = note->descsz;
9417 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9418 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9423 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
9425 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
9430 sect->size = note->descsz;
9431 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9432 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9441 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
9443 void *ddata = note->descdata;
9450 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
9451 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
9453 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
9454 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
9456 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
9457 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
9459 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
9460 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
9462 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
9463 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
9466 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
9467 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
9468 thread just in case. */
9469 if (flags & 0x00000080)
9470 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
9472 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
9473 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
9475 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
9480 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9484 sect->size = note->descsz;
9485 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9486 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9488 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
9492 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
9493 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9501 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
9502 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
9504 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
9509 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9513 sect->size = note->descsz;
9514 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9515 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9517 /* This is the current thread. */
9518 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
9519 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
9524 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
9525 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
9526 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
9527 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
9530 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9532 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
9533 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
9535 static long tid = 1;
9539 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
9540 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
9541 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
9542 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
9543 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
9544 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
9545 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
9546 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
9553 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9559 /* Use note name as section name. */
9561 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9564 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
9565 name[len - 1] = '\0';
9567 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9571 sect->size = note->descsz;
9572 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9573 sect->alignment_power = 1;
9578 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
9581 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
9585 size of data for note
9587 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
9588 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
9589 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
9590 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
9593 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
9596 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
9604 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
9611 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
9613 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
9615 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
9618 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
9619 *bufsiz += newspace;
9620 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
9621 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
9622 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
9623 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
9627 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
9635 memcpy (dest, input, size);
9646 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
9652 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9654 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
9657 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9658 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
9663 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9664 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9665 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9667 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9669 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
9672 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
9675 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9676 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
9677 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
9678 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9679 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
9684 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9686 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
9689 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
9692 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9693 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
9694 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
9695 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9696 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
9698 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
9705 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
9706 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9707 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
9709 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32 data;
9711 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9712 LINUX_PRPSINFO32_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
9714 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
9715 &data, sizeof (data));
9719 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
9720 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9721 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
9723 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64 data;
9725 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9726 LINUX_PRPSINFO64_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
9728 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9729 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
9733 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
9740 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9742 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
9745 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9747 pid, cursig, gregs);
9752 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9753 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9754 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9756 prstatus32_t prstat;
9758 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
9759 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
9760 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9761 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
9762 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
9763 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
9770 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
9771 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
9772 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9773 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
9774 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
9775 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
9777 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
9783 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9785 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
9792 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9793 const char *note_name = "CORE";
9795 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
9796 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
9797 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9798 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9799 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
9800 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9802 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
9803 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
9805 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
9806 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
9809 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9810 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
9812 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
9814 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9816 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
9820 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9821 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9823 const char *note_name = "CORE";
9824 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9825 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9827 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9831 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9832 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9833 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9834 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9842 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9843 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9844 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9845 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9849 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
9852 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9858 const char *note_name = "CORE";
9859 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9860 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
9864 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9867 const void *xfpregs,
9870 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9871 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9872 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
9876 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9877 const void *xfpregs, int size)
9880 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
9881 note_name = "FreeBSD";
9883 note_name = "LINUX";
9884 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9885 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
9889 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
9892 const void *ppc_vmx,
9895 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9896 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9897 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
9901 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
9904 const void *ppc_vsx,
9907 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9908 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9909 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
9913 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
9916 const void *s390_high_gprs,
9919 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9920 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9921 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
9922 s390_high_gprs, size);
9926 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
9929 const void *s390_timer,
9932 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9933 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9934 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
9938 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
9941 const void *s390_todcmp,
9944 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9945 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9946 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
9950 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
9953 const void *s390_todpreg,
9956 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9957 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9958 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
9962 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
9965 const void *s390_ctrs,
9968 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9969 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9970 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
9974 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
9977 const void *s390_prefix,
9980 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9981 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9982 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
9986 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
9989 const void *s390_last_break,
9992 char *note_name = "LINUX";
9993 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9994 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
9995 s390_last_break, size);
9999 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10002 const void *s390_system_call,
10005 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10006 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10007 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10008 s390_system_call, size);
10012 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10015 const void *s390_tdb,
10018 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10019 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10020 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10024 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10027 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10030 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10031 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10032 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10036 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10039 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10042 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10043 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10044 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10045 s390_vxrs_high, size);
10049 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
10052 const void *arm_vfp,
10055 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10056 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10057 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
10061 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
10064 const void *aarch_tls,
10067 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10068 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10069 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
10073 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
10076 const void *aarch_hw_break,
10079 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10080 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10081 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
10085 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
10088 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
10091 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10092 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10093 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
10097 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
10100 const char *section,
10104 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
10105 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10106 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
10107 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10108 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
10109 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10110 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
10111 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10112 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
10113 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10114 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
10115 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10116 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
10117 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10118 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
10119 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10120 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
10121 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10122 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
10123 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10124 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
10125 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10126 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
10127 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10128 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
10129 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10130 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
10131 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10132 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
10133 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10134 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
10135 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10136 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
10137 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10138 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
10139 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10140 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
10141 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10142 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
10143 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10148 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
10153 while (p < buf + size)
10155 /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
10156 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
10157 Elf_Internal_Note in;
10159 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
10162 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
10164 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
10165 in.namedata = xnp->name;
10166 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
10169 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
10170 in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
10171 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
10173 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
10174 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
10177 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
10184 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
10187 const char * string;
10189 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
10193 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
10194 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
10195 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
10196 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
10197 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
10199 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
10202 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
10204 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
10205 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
10206 grokers[i].len) == 0)
10208 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
10217 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
10219 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
10222 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
10223 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
10225 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
10231 p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
10238 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
10245 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
10248 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
10252 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
10253 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
10256 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
10257 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
10267 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
10269 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
10270 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
10271 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
10274 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
10276 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10278 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
10282 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
10285 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
10286 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
10287 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
10288 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
10290 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
10291 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
10294 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
10298 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10300 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
10304 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
10305 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
10306 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
10311 enum elf_reloc_type_class
10312 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10313 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10314 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10316 return reloc_class_normal;
10319 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
10320 relocation against a local symbol. */
10323 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
10324 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10326 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
10328 asection *sec = *psec;
10329 bfd_vma relocation;
10331 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
10332 + sec->output_offset
10334 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
10335 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
10336 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
10339 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
10340 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
10341 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
10344 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
10345 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
10346 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
10347 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
10348 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
10349 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
10350 sec->kept_section = *psec;
10353 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
10354 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
10360 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
10361 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10365 asection *sec = *psec;
10367 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
10368 return sym->st_value + addend;
10370 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
10371 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
10372 sym->st_value + addend);
10376 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
10377 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10381 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
10383 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
10384 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
10386 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
10387 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
10389 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
10391 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10392 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
10393 offset = sec->size - offset - address_size;
10399 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
10400 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
10401 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
10402 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
10403 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
10404 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
10406 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
10407 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
10408 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
10409 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
10410 the remote memory. */
10413 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
10416 bfd_size_type size,
10417 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
10418 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
10420 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
10421 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
10425 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
10426 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10427 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10432 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10435 const char *relplt_name;
10436 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
10440 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
10446 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
10449 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
10452 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
10455 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
10456 if (relplt_name == NULL)
10457 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
10458 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
10459 if (relplt == NULL)
10462 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
10463 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
10464 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
10467 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
10471 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
10472 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
10475 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
10476 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
10477 p = relplt->relocation;
10478 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
10480 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
10481 if (p->addend != 0)
10484 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
10486 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
10491 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
10495 names = (char *) (s + count);
10496 p = relplt->relocation;
10498 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
10503 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
10504 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
10507 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
10508 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
10509 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
10510 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
10511 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
10512 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
10514 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
10517 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
10518 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
10520 if (p->addend != 0)
10524 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
10525 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
10526 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
10527 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
10530 memcpy (names, a, len);
10533 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
10534 names += sizeof ("@plt");
10541 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far. */
10542 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
10543 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
10544 SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
10547 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
10548 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10550 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
10552 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
10554 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
10556 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
10557 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
10558 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
10559 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
10560 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
10561 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
10565 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
10566 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
10567 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
10570 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
10572 return (type == STT_FUNC
10573 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
10576 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
10577 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
10578 otherwise return zero. */
10581 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
10584 bfd_size_type size;
10586 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
10587 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
10588 || sym->section != sec)
10591 *code_off = sym->value;
10593 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
10594 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;